1#ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2#define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3/*
4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5 *
6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13 * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14 * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
15 *
16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19 *
20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27 *
28 */
29
30/*
31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34 *
35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39 * can actually be identified and removed.
40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41 */
42
43#include <linux/types.h>
44
45#define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46
47#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54
55#define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56#define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57#define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58#define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59
60/**
61 * DOC: Station handling
62 *
63 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67 * to.
68 *
69 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70 * capabilities.
71 *
72 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74 *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75 *    or capability information; this just exists to avoid race conditions
76 *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77 *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78 *    time mark it authorized.
79 *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80 *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81 *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82 *
83 * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84 */
85
86/**
87 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88 *
89 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant to react to management frames
91 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93 * for various reasons.
94 *
95 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101 * for doing that.
102 *
103 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105 * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106 *
107 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108 *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109 *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110 *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111 *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112 *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113 *
114 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame is transmitted, its
117 * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118 *
119 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120 * below.
121 */
122
123/**
124 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125 *
126 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs; they can have
127 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129 * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130 *
131 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133 * types there no concurrency is implied.
134 *
135 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138 * an additional list of these; they can be added at any time and
139 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142 *
143 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151 *
152 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153 * interfaces that a given device supports.
154 */
155
156/**
157 * DOC: packet coalesce support
158 *
159 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162 * and power consumption.
163 *
164 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167 * following events occurs.
168 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches its limit.
171 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172 *
173 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174 * rule.
175 * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177 * c) Condition for coalescence: pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178 * Multiple such rules can be created.
179 */
180
181/**
182 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183 *
184 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186 * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191 *
192 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195 * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196 * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197 * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198 * not present.
199 *
200 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202 * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207 *
208 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211 */
212
213/**
214 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215 *
216 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertised by drivers by
217 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231 *
232 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234 * up a connection or after roaming.
235 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238 *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241 *
242 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertised by a FILS
243 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249 */
250
251/**
252 * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253 *
254 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255 * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256 * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257 * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258 *
259 * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261 * respectively.
262 */
263
264/**
265 * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266 *
267 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268 * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269 * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270 * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271 * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272 * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273 * that main netdev.
274 *
275 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277 * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278 */
279
280/**
281 * DOC: TID configuration
282 *
283 * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284 * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285 *
286 * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287 * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289 *
290 * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291 * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292 * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293 * any peers that have peer-specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294 * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer-specific values
295 * will be overwritten.
296 *
297 * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection,
298 * i.e., the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299 * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300 * the interface goes down.
301 */
302
303/**
304 * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305 *
306 * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307 *
308 * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310 * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311 * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312 * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313 *
314 * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315 * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316 * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317 * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321 *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322 *
323 * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324 */
325
326/**
327 * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328 *
329 * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between two MLDs utilizes multiple
330 * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331 * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332 * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333 * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334 * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335 */
336
337/**
338 * DOC: OWE DH IE handling offload
339 *
340 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD flag, drivers can indicate
341 * kernel/application space to avoid DH IE handling. When this flag is
342 * advertised, the driver/device will take care of DH IE inclusion and
343 * processing of peer DH IE to generate PMK.
344 */
345
346/**
347 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
348 *
349 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
350 *
351 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
352 *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
353 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
354 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
355 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
356 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
357 *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
358 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
359 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
360 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
361 *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
362 *	compatibility only.
363 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
364 *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
365 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
366 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
367 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
368 *
369 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
370 *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
371 *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
372 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
373 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
374 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
375 *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
376 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
377 *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
378 *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
379 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
380 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
381 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
382 *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
383 *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
384 *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
385 *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
386 *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
387 *
388 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
389 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
390 *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
391 *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
393 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
394 *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
395 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
397 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
398 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
399 *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
400 *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
401 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
402 *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
403 *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
404 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
405 *
406 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
407 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
408 *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
409 *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
410 *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
411 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
412 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
413 *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
414 *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
415 *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
416 *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
417 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
418 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
419 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
420 *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
421 *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
422 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
423 *	attributes determining channel width.
424 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
425 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
426 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
427 *
428 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
429 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
430 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
431 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
432 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
433 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
434 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
435 *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
436 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
437 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
438 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
439 *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
440 *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
441 *	frame). %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID can be used optionally to remove
442 *	stations connected and using at least that link as one of its links.
443 *
444 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
445 * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
446 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
447 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
448 * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
449 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
450 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
451 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
452 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
453 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
454 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
455 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
456 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
457 *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
458 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
459 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
460 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
461 *
462 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
463 *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
464 *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
465 *	global regdomain will be returned.
466 *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
467 *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
468 *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
469 *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
470 *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
471 *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
472 *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
473 *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
474 *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
475 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
476 *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
477 *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
478 *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
479 * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
480 * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
481 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
482 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
483 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
484 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
485 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
486 * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
487 * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
488 *
489 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
490 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
491 *
492 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
493 *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
494 *
495 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
496 *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
497 *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
498 *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
499 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
500 *	added to all specified management frames generated by
501 *	kernel/firmware/driver.
502 *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
503 *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
504 *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
505 *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
506 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
507 *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
508 *
509 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
510 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
511 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
512 *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
513 *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
514 *	be used.
515 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
516 *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
517 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
518 *	partial scan results may be available
519 *
520 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
521 *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
522 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
523 *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
524 *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
525 *	These attributes are mutually exclusive,
526 *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
527 *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
528 *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
529 *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
530 *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
531 *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
532 *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
533 *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
534 *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
535 *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
536 *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
537 *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
538 *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
539 *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
540 *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
541 *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
542 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
543 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
544 *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
545 *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
546 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
547 *	results available.
548 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
549 *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
550 *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
551 *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
552 *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
553 *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
554 *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
555 *
556 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey results, e.g. channel occupation
557 *      or noise level
558 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
559 *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
560 *
561 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
562 *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
563 *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
564 *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
565 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
566 *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
567 *	advertised by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
568 *	ESS.
569 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
570 *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
571 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
572 *	authentication. Additionally in case of SAE offload and OWE offloads
573 *	PMKSA entry can be deleted using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID.
574 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
575 *
576 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
577 * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
578 * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
579 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
580 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
581 * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
582 * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
583 * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
584 * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
585 * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
586 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
587 * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
588 * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
589 * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
590 * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
591 * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
592 * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
593 * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
594 * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
595 * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
596 * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
597 * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
598 * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
599 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
600 * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
601 * 	the beacon hint was processed.
602 *
603 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
604 *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
605 *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
606 *	authentication process.
607 *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
608 *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
609 *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
610 *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
611 *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
612 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequency of the
613 *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
614 *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
615 *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
616 *	to the frame.
617 *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
618 *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
619 *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
620 *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
621 *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
622 *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
623 *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
624 *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
625 *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
626 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
627 *	pending authentication timed out).
628 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
629 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
630 *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
631 *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
632 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
633 *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
634 *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
635 *	included).
636 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
637 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
638 *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
639 *	primitives).
640 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
641 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
642 *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
643 *
644 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
645 *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
646 *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
647 *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
648 *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
649 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
650 *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
651 *
652 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
653 *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
654 *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
655 *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
656 *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
657 *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
658 *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
659 *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
660 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
661 *	determined by the network interface.
662 *
663 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
664 *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
665 *	to the driver.
666 *
667 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
668 *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
669 *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
670 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
671 *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
672 *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
673 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
674 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
675 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
676 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
677 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
678 *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
679 *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
680 *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
681 *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
682 *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
683 *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
684 *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
685 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
686 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
687 *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
688 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
689 *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
690 *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
691 *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
692 *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
693 *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
694 *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
695 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
696 *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
697 *	a different BSS is desired.
698 *	Background scan period can optionally be
699 *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
700 *	if not specified default background scan configuration
701 *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
702 *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
703 *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
704 *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
705 *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
706 *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
707 *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
708 *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
709 *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
710 *	well to remain backwards compatible.
711 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
712 *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
713 *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
714 *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
715 *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
716 *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
717 *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
718 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
719 *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
720 *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
721 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
722 *
723 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
724 *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
725 *
726 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
727 *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
728 *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
729 *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
730 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
731 *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
732 *	frequency for the operation.
733 *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
734 *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
735 *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
736 *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
737 *	radio).
738 *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
739 *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
740 *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
741 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
742 *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
743 *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
744 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
745 *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
746 *	uniquely identify the request.
747 *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
748 *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
749 *
750 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
751 *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
752 *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
753 *
754 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
755 *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
756 *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
757 *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
758 *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
759 *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
760 *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
761 *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
762 *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
763 *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
764 *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
765 *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
766 *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
767 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
768 *	backward compatibility
769 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
770 *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
771 *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
772 *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
773 *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
774 *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
775 *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
776 *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
777 *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
778 *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
779 *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
780 *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
781 *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
782 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
783 *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
784 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
785 *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
786 *	is used during CSA period.
787 *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
788 *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
789 *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
790 *	lower layers.
791 *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
792 *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
793 *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
794 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
795 *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
796 *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
797 *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
798 *	wait time.
799 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
800 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
801 *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
802 *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
803 *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
804 *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
805 *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
806 *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
807 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
808 *	backward compatibility.
809 *
810 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
811 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
812 *
813 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
814 *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
815 *	levels.
816 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
817 *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
818 *	reached.
819 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
820 *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
821 *	(identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
822 *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
823 *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
824 *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
825 *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
826 *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
827 *	precedence when they are used.
828 *
829 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
830 *	(no longer supported).
831 *
832 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
833 *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
834 *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
835 *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
836 *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
837 *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
838 *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
839 *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
840 *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
841 *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
842 *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
843 *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
844 *	command, the feature is disabled.
845 *
846 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
847 *	mesh config parameters may be given.
848 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
849 *	network is determined by the network interface.
850 *
851 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
852 *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
853 *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
854 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
855 *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
856 *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
857 *
858 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
859 *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
860 *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
861 *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
862 *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
863 *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
864 *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
865 *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
866 *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
867 *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
868 *      depending on the authentication result.
869 *
870 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
871 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
872 *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
873 *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
874 *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
875 *	more background information, see
876 *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
877 *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
878 *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
879 *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
880 *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
881 *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
882 *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
883 *
884 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
885 *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
886 *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
887 *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
888 *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
889 *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
890 *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
891 *
892 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
893 *	of PMKSA caching candidates.
894 *
895 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
896 *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
897 *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
898 *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
899 *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
900 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
901 *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
902 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
903 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
904 *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
905 *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
906 *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
907 *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
908 *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
909 *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
910 *
911 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
912 *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
913 *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
914 *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
915 *	is received.
916 *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
917 *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
918 *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
919 *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
920 *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
921 *
922 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
923 *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
924 *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
925 *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
926 *
927 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
928 *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
929 *	acknowledged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
930 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
931 *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
932 *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
933 *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
934 *
935 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
936 *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
937 *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
938 *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
939 *
940 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
941 *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
942 *
943 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
944 *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
945 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
946 *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
947 *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
948 *	from the remote AP) is completed;
949 *
950 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
951 *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
952 *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
953 *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
954 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
955 *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
956 *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
957 *	interfaces to change channel as well.
958 *
959 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
960 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
961 *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
962 *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
963 *	public action frame TX.
964 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
965 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
966 *
967 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
968 *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
969 *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
970 *	is used for this.
971 *
972 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
973 *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
974 *
975 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
976 *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
977 *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
978 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
979 *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
980 *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
981 *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
982 *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
983 *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
984 *
985 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
986 *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
987 *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
988 *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
989 *	while operating on this channel.
990 *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
991 *	event.
992 *
993 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
994 *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
995 *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
996 *
997 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
998 *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
999 *
1000 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
1001 *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
1002 *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
1003 *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
1004 *
1005 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
1006 *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
1007 *	complete.
1008 *
1009 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
1010 *	return back to normal.
1011 *
1012 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1013 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1014 *
1015 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1016 *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1017 *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1018 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1019 *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1020 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1021 *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1022 *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1023 *	switch is complete.
1024 *
1025 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1026 *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1027 *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1028 *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1029 *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1030 *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1031 *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1032 *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1033 *
1034 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1035 *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1036 *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1037 *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1038 *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1039 *
1040 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1041 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1042 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1043 *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1044 *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1045 *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1046 *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1047 *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1048 *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1049 *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1050 *	fail even if the check was successful.
1051 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1052 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1053 *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1054 *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1055 *
1056 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1057 *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1058 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1059 *
1060 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1061 *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1062 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1063 *	network is determined by the network interface.
1064 *
1065 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1066 *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1067 *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1068 *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1069 *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1070 *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1071 *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1072 *	AP.
1073 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1074 *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1075 *	when this command completes.
1076 *
1077 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1078 *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1079 *	management.
1080 *
1081 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1082 *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1083 *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1084 *
1085 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1086 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1087 *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1088 *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1089 *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1090 *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1091 *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1092 *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1093 *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1094 *	added.
1095 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1096 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1097 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1098 *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1099 *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1100 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1101 *	of the function upon success.
1102 *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1103 *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1104 *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1105 *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1106 *	which just terminated.
1107 *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1108 *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1109 *	the response to this command.
1110 *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1111 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1112 *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1113 *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1114 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1115 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1116 *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1117 *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1118 *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1119 *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1120 *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1121 *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1122 *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1123 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1124 *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1125 *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1126 *
1127 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1128 *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1129 *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1130 *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1131 *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1132 *
1133 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1134 *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1135 *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1136 *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1137 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1138 *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1139 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1140 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates port is authorized and
1141 *	open for regular data traffic. For STA/P2P-client, this event is sent
1142 *	with AP MAC address and for AP/P2P-GO, the event carries the STA/P2P-
1143 *	client MAC address.
1144 *	Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload should send this event for
1145 *	STA/P2P-client after successful 4-way HS or after 802.1X FT following
1146 *	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or NL80211_CMD_ROAM. Drivers using AP/P2P-GO 4-way
1147 *	handshake offload should send this event on successful completion of
1148 *	4-way handshake with the peer (STA/P2P-client).
1149 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1150 *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1151 *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1152 *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1153 *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1154 *	802.11 headers.
1155 *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1156 *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1157 *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1158 *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1159 *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1160 *	address of that link.
1161 *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1162 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1163 *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1164 *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1165 *
1166 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1167 *
1168 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1169 *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1170 *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1171 *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1172 *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1173 *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1174 *
1175 *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1176 *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1177 *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1178 *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1179 *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1180 *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1181 *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1182 *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1183 *	command interface.
1184 *
1185 *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1186 *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1187 *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1188 *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1189 *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1190 *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1191 *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1192 *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1193 *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1194 *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1195 *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1196 *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1197 *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1198 *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1199 *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1200 *	authentication.
1201 *
1202 *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1203 *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1204 *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1205 *
1206 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1207 *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1208 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1209 *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1210 *
1211 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1212 *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1213 *
1214 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1215 *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1216 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1217 *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1218 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1219 *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1220 *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1221 *	the netlink extended ack message.
1222 *
1223 *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1224 *
1225 *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1226 *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1227 *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1228 *	buffer size.
1229 *
1230 *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1231 *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1232 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1233 *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1234 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1235 *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1236 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1237 *
1238 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1239 *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1240 *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1241 *	determining the width and type.
1242 *
1243 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1244 *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1245 *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1246 *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1247 *
1248 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1249 *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1250 *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1251 *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1252 *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1253 *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1254 *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1255 *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1256 *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1257 *	rate selection.
1258 *
1259 *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1260 *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1261 *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1262 *
1263 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1264 *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1265 *
1266 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1267 *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1268 *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1269 *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1270 *
1271 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1272 *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1273 *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1274 *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1275 *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1276 *
1277 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1278 *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1279 *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1280 *
1281 * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1282 *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1283 *
1284 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1285 *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1286 *
1287 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1288 *	started
1289 *
1290 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1291 *	been aborted
1292 *
1293 * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1294 *	has completed
1295 *
1296 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1297 *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1298 *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1299 *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1300 *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1301 *
1302 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1303 *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1304 *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1305 *      specify the timeout value.
1306 *
1307 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1308 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1309 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1310 *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1311 *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1312 *
1313 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1314 * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1315 * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1316 *
1317 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1318 *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1319 *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1320 *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1321 *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1322 *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1323 *	HW timestamping.
1324 *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1325 *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1326 *
1327 * @NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED: Notify userspace about the removal of STA MLD
1328 *	setup links due to AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with
1329 *	Multi-Link reconfiguration. %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS is used to provide
1330 *	information about the removed STA MLD setup links.
1331 *
1332 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING: Set the TID to Link Mapping for a
1333 *      non-AP MLD station. The %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK and
1334 *      %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK attributes are used to specify the
1335 *      TID to Link mapping for downlink/uplink traffic.
1336 *
1337 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1338 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1339 */
1340enum nl80211_commands {
1341/* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1342	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1343
1344	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1345	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1346	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1347	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1348
1349	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1350	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1351	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1352	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1353
1354	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1355	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1356	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1357	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1358
1359	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1360	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1361	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1362	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1363	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1364	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1365
1366	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1367	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1368	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1369	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1370
1371	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1372	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1373	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1374	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1375
1376	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1377
1378	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1379	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1380
1381	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1382	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1383
1384	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1385
1386	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1387
1388	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1389	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1390	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1391	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1392
1393	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1394
1395	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1396	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1397	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1398	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1399
1400	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1401
1402	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1403
1404	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1405	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1406
1407	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1408
1409	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1410	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1411	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1412
1413	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1414
1415	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1416	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1417
1418	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1419	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1420	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1421
1422	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1423	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1424
1425	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1426
1427	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1428	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1429	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1430	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1431	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1432	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1433
1434	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1435	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1436
1437	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1438	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1439
1440	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1441	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1442
1443	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1444
1445	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1446	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1447
1448	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1449	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1450
1451	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1452
1453	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1454	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1455
1456	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1457	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1458	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1459	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1460
1461	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1462
1463	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1464
1465	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1466	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1467
1468	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1469
1470	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1471
1472	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1473
1474	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1475
1476	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1477
1478	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1479
1480	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1481	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1482
1483	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1484
1485	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1486
1487	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1488
1489	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1490
1491	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1492
1493	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1494	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1495
1496	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1497	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1498
1499	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1500	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1501
1502	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1503
1504	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1505
1506	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1507
1508	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1509	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1510
1511	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1512
1513	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1514	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1515
1516	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1517
1518	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1519	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1520
1521	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1522
1523	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1524
1525	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1526	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1527	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1528	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1529	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1530	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1531
1532	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1533
1534	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1535
1536	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1537	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1538
1539	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1540
1541	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1542
1543	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1544
1545	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1546
1547	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1548
1549	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1550
1551	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1552	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1553	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1554
1555	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1556
1557	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1558
1559	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1560
1561	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1562
1563	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1564
1565	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1566
1567	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1568
1569	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1570
1571	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1572
1573	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1574	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1575	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1576
1577	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1578
1579	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1580
1581	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1582	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1583
1584	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1585	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1586	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1587
1588	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1589
1590	NL80211_CMD_LINKS_REMOVED,
1591
1592	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_TO_LINK_MAPPING,
1593
1594	/* add new commands above here */
1595
1596	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1597	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1598	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1599};
1600
1601/*
1602 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1603 * here
1604 */
1605#define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1606#define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1607#define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1608#define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1609#define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1610#define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1611#define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1612#define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1613
1614#define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1615
1616/* source-level API compatibility */
1617#define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1618#define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1619#define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1620
1621/**
1622 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1623 *
1624 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1625 *
1626 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1627 *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1628 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1629 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1630 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1631 *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1632 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1633 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1634 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1635 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1636 *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1637 *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1638 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1639 *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1640 *	operating channel center frequency.
1641 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1642 *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1643 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1644 *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1645 *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1646 *		this attribute)
1647 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1648 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1649 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1650 *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1651 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1652 *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1653 *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1654 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1655 *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1656 *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1657 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1658 *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1659 *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1660 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1661 *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1662 *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1663 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1664 *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1665 *
1666 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1667 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1668 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1669 *
1670 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1671 *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1672 *
1673 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1674 *
1675 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1676 *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1677 *	keys
1678 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1679 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1680 *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1681 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1682 *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1683 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1684 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1685 *	default management key
1686 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1687 *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1688 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1689 *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1690 *
1691 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1692 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1693 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1694 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1695 *
1696 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1697 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1698 *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1699 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1700 *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1701 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1702 *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1703 *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1704 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1705 *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1706 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1707 *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1708 *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1709 *
1710 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1711 *	consisting of a nested array.
1712 *
1713 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1714 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1715 *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1716 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1717 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1718 * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1719 *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1720 *
1721 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1722 *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1723 *
1724 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1725 * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1726 * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1727 * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1728 * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1729 * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1730 * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1731 * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1732 * 	to a specific alpha2.
1733 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1734 *	rules.
1735 *
1736 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1737 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1738 *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1739 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1740 *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1741 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1742 *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1743 *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1744 *
1745 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1746 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1747 *
1748 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1749 *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1750 *	of the interface mode.
1751 *
1752 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1753 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1754 *
1755 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1756 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1757 *
1758 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1759 *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1760 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1761 *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1762 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1763 *	that can be added to a scan request
1764 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1765 *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1766 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1767 *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1768 *
1769 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1770 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1771 *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1772 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1773 *
1774 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1775 * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1776 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1777 * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1778 *
1779 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1780 *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1781 *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1782 *
1783 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1784 *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1785 *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1786 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1787 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1788 *	represented as a u32
1789 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1790 *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1791 *
1792 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1793 *	a u32
1794 *
1795 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1796 * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1797 * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1798 * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1799 * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1800 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1801 * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1802 * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1803 * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1804 * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1805 *
1806 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1807 *	cipher suites
1808 *
1809 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1810 *	for other networks on different channels
1811 *
1812 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1813 *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1814 *
1815 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1816 *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1817 *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1818 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1819 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1820 *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1821 *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1822 *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1823 *
1824 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1825 *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1826 *
1827 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1828 *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1829 *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1830 *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1831 *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1832 *	default in station mode.
1833 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1834 *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1835 *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1836 *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1837 *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1838 *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1839 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1840 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1841 *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1842 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1843 *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1844 *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1845 *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1846 *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1847 *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1848 *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1849 *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1850 *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1851 *	frames are not forwarded over the control port.
1852 *
1853 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1854 *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1855 *
1856 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1857 *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1858 *	a local disconnect request.
1859 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1860 *	event (u16)
1861 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1862 *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1863 *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1864 *
1865 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1866 *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1867 *	(an array of u32).
1868 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1869 *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1870 *	u32).
1871 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1872 *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1873 *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1874 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1875 *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1876 *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1877 *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1878 *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1879 *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1880 *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1881 *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1882 *
1883 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1884 *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1885 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1886 *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1887 *
1888 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1889 *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1890 *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1891 *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1892 *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1893 *
1894 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1895 *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1896 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1897 *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1898 *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1899 *
1900 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1901 *
1902 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1903 *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1904 *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1905 *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1906 *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1907 *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1908 *	completely from scratch.
1909 *
1910 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1911 *
1912 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1913 *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1914 *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1915 *
1916 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1917 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1918 *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1919 *
1920 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1921 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1922 *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1923 *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1924 *
1925 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1926 *
1927 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1928 *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1929 *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1930 *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1931 *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1932 *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1933 *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1934 *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1935 *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1936 *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1937 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1938 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1939 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1940 *
1941 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1942 *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1943 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1944 *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1945 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1946 *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1947 *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1948 *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1949 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1950 *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1951 *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1952 *
1953 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1954 *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1955 *
1956 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1957 *
1958 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1959 *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1960 *
1961 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1962 *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1963 *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1964 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1965 *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1966 *
1967 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1968 *	connected to this BSS.
1969 *
1970 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1971 *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1972 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1973 *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1974 *      for non-automatic settings.
1975 *
1976 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1977 *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1978 *
1979 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1980 *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1981 *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1982 *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1983 *
1984 *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1985 *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1986 *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1987 *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1988 *	a chain has diversity antennas whether diversity should be used or not.
1989 *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1990 *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1991 *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive whether to use diversity or not.
1992 *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1993 *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1994 *
1995 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1996 *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1997 *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1998 *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1999 *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
2000 *
2001 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2002 *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
2003 *
2004 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
2005 *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
2006 *
2007 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
2008 *
2009 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
2010 *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
2011 *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
2012 *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
2013 *	nl80211 capability flag.
2014 *
2015 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
2016 *
2017 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
2018 *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
2019 *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
2020 *
2021 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
2022 *	changed once the mesh is active.
2023 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
2024 *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
2025 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
2026 *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
2027 *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
2028 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2029 *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2030 *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2031 *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2032 *
2033 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2034 *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2035 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2036 *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2037 *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2038 *	triggers.
2039 *
2040 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2041 *	cycles, in msecs.
2042 *
2043 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2044 *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2045 *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2046 *	pass-thru filter rules.
2047 *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2048 *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2049 *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2050 *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2051 *	able to ignore them by itself.
2052 *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2053 *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2054 *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2055 *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2056 *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2057 *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2058 *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2059 *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2060 *
2061 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2062 *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2063 *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2064 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2065 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2066 *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2067 *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2068 *
2069 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2070 *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2071 *
2072 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2073 *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2074 *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2075 *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2076 *
2077 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2078 *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2079 *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2080 *
2081 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2082 *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2083 *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2084 *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2085 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2086 *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2087 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2088 *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2089 *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2090 *
2091 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2092 *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2093 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2094 *	as AP.
2095 *
2096 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2097 *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2098 *
2099 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2100 *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2101 *
2102 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2103 *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2104 *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2105 *	applications use this attribute.
2106 *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2107 *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2108 *
2109 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2110 *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2111 *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2112 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2113 *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2114 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2115 *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2116 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2117 *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2118 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2119 *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2120 *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2121 *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2122 *
2123 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2124 *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2125 *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2126 *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2127 *
2128 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2129 *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2130 *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2131 *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2132 *
2133 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2134 *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2135 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2136 *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2137 *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2138 *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2139 *
2140 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2141 *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2142 *	to be filled by the FW.
2143 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2144 *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2145 *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2146 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2147 *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2148 *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2149 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2150 *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2151 *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2152 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2153 *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2154 *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2155 *      The values that may be configured are:
2156 *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2157 *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2158 *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2159 *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2160 *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2161 *
2162 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2163 *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2164 *    to one DFS region.
2165 *
2166 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2167 *      up to 16 TIDs.
2168 *
2169 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2170 *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2171 *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2172 *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2173 *	capability to timeout the stations.
2174 *
2175 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2176 *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2177 *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2178 *
2179 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2180 *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2181 *
2182 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2183 *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2184 *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2185 *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2186 *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2187 *
2188 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2189 *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2190 *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2191 *
2192 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2193 *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2194 *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2195 *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2196 *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2197 *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2198 *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2199 *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2200 *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2201 *	consistent.
2202 *
2203 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2204 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2205 *
2206 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2207 *
2208 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2209 *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2210 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2211 *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2212 *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2213 *	no change is made.
2214 *
2215 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2216 *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2217 *
2218 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2219 *	carried in a u32 attribute
2220 *
2221 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2222 *	MAC ACL.
2223 *
2224 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2225 *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2226 *	ACL.
2227 *
2228 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2229 *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2230 *
2231 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2232 *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2233 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2234 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2235 *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2236 *
2237 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2238 *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2239 *
2240 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2241 *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2242 *	and PU-APSD.
2243 *
2244 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2245 *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2246 *
2247 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2248 *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2249 *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2250 *
2251 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2252 *
2253 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2254 *	Element
2255 *
2256 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2257 *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2258 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2259 *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2260 *
2261 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2262 *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2263 *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2264 *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2265 *
2266 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2267 *
2268 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2269 *	until the channel switch event.
2270 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2271 *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2272 *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2273 *	was requested by the AP.
2274 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2275 *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2276 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2277 *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2278 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2279 *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2280 *
2281 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2282 *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2283 *
2284 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2285 *
2286 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2287 *      operating classes.
2288 *
2289 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2290 *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2291 *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2292 *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2293 *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2294 *	IBSS network.
2295 *
2296 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2297 *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2298 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2299 *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2300 *
2301 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2302 *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2303 *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2304 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2305 *	u8 attribute.
2306 *
2307 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2308 *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2309 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2310 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2311 *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2312 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2313 *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2314 *
2315 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2316 *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2317 *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2318 *
2319 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2320 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2321 *
2322 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2323 *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2324 *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2325 *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2326 *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2327 *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2328 *
2329 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2330 *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2331 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2332 *	supported number of csa counters.
2333 *
2334 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2335 *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2336 *
2337 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2338 *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2339 *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2340 *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2341 *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2342 *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2343 *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2344 *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2345 *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2346 *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2347 *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2348 *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2349 *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2350 *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2351 *	multicast group.
2352 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2353 *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2354 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2355 *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2356 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2357 *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2358 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2359 *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2360 *
2361 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2362 *	the TDLS link initiator.
2363 *
2364 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2365 *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2366 *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2367 *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2368 *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2369 *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2370 *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2371 *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2372 *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2373 *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2374 *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2375 *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2376 *
2377 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2378 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2379 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2380 *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2381 *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2382 *
2383 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2384 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2385 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2386 *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2387 *
2388 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2389 *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2390 *
2391 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2392 *
2393 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2394 *
2395 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2396 *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2397 *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2398 *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2399 *
2400 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2401 *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2402 *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2403 *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2404 *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2405 *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2406 *
2407 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2408 *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2409 *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2410 *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2411 *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2412 *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2413 *	over all channels.
2414 *
2415 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2416 *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2417 *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2418 *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2419
2420 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2421 *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2422 *
2423 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2424 *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2425 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2426 *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2427 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2428 *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2429 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2430 *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2431 *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2432 *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2433 *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2434 *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2435 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2436 *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2437 *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2438 *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2439 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2440 *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2441 *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2442 *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2443 *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2444 *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2445 *
2446 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2447 *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2448 *
2449 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2450 *
2451 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2452 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2453 *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2454 *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2455 *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2456 *	present.
2457 *
2458 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2459 *	groupID for monitor mode.
2460 *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2461 *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2462 *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2463 *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2464 *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2465 *	each group.
2466 *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2467 *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2468 *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2469 *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2470 *	groupID data.
2471 *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2472 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2473 *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2474 *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2475 *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2476 *
2477 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2478 *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2479 *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2480 *	attribute must not be included).
2481 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2482 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2483 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2484 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2485 *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2486 *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2487 *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2488 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2489 *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2490 *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2491 *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2492 *
2493 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2494 *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2495 *
2496 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2497 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2498 *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2499 *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2500 *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2501 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2502 *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2503 *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2504 *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2505 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2506 *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2507 *	the device will decide what to use.
2508 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2509 *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2510 *	attribute.
2511 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2512 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2513 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2514 *	protection.
2515 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2516 *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2517 *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2518 *
2519 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2520 *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2521 *
2522 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2523 *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2524 *
2525 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2526 *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2527 *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2528 *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2529 *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2530 *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2531 *	unnecessary wakeups.
2532 *
2533 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2534 *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2535 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2536 *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2537 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2538 *
2539 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2540 *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2541 *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2542 *
2543 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2544 *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2545 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2546 *
2547 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2548 *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2549 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2550 *
2551 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2552 *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2553 *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2554 *
2555 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2556 *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2557 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2558 *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2559 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2560 *
2561 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertised by a FILS AP
2562 *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2563 *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2564 *
2565 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2566 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2567 *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2568 *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2569 *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2570 *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2571 *	is included as well.
2572 *
2573 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2574 *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2575 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2576 *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2577 *
2578 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2579 *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2580 *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2581 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2582 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2583 *
2584 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2585 *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2586 *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2587 *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2588 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2589 *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2590 *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2591 *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2592 *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2593 *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2594 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2595 *
2596 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2597 *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2598 *
2599 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2600 *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2601 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2602 *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2603 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2604 *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2605 *      enforced.
2606 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2607 *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2608 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2609 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2610 *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2611 *
2612 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2613 *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2614 *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2615 *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2616 *
2617 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2618 *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2619 *
2620 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2621 *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2622 *	invalid value.
2623 *
2624 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2625 *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2626 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2627 *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2628 *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2629 *
2630 * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2631 *	scheduler.
2632 *
2633 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2634 *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2635 *	possible values.
2636 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2637 *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2638 *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2639 *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2640 *	or per-station.
2641 *
2642 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2643 *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2644 *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2645 *
2646 * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2647 *
2648 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2649 *	functionality.
2650 *
2651 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2652 *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2653 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2654 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2655 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2656 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2657 *
2658 * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2659 *	(u16).
2660 *
2661 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2662 *
2663 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2664 *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2665 *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2666 *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2667 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2668 *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2669 *
2670 * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2671 *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2672 *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2673 *	attributes.
2674 *
2675 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2676 *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2677 *
2678 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2679 *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2680 *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2681 *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2682 *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2683 *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2684 *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2685 *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2686 *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2687 *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2688 *
2689 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2690 *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2691 *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2692 *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2693 *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2694 *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2695 *	has expired.
2696 *
2697 *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2698 *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2699 *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2700 *	disassociation is still forced.
2701 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2702 *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2703 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2704 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2705 *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2706 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2707 *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2708 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2709 *
2710 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2711 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2712 *
2713 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2714 *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2715 *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2716 *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2717 *
2718 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2719 *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2720 *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes. Userspace should pass an empty
2721 *	nested attribute to disable this feature and delete the templates.
2722 *
2723 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2724 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2725 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2726 *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2727 *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2728 *
2729 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2730 *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2731 *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2732 *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2733 *
2734 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2735 *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2736 *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2737 *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2738 *
2739 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2740 *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2741 *	is desired.
2742 *
2743 * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2744 *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2745 *
2746 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2747 *	until the color switch event.
2748 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2749 *	switching to
2750 * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2751 *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2752 *
2753 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2754 *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2755 *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2756 *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2757 *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2758 *	parameters.
2759 *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2760 *
2761 * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2762 *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2763 *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2764 *
2765 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2766 *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2767 *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2768 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2769 *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2770 *	radar channel.
2771 *
2772 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2773 *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2774 *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2775 *
2776 * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2777 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2778 *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2779 *
2780 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2781 *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2782 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2783 *	per-link information and a link ID.
2784 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2785 *	authenticate/associate.
2786 *
2787 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2788 *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2789 *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2790 *
2791 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2792 *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2793 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2794 *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2795 *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2796 *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2797 *
2798 * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2799 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2800 *
2801 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2802 *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2803 *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2804 *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2805 *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2806 *	the ack TX timestamp.
2807 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2808 *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2809 *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2810 *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2811 *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2812 *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2813 * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2814 *	(re)associations.
2815 *
2816 * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2817 *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2818 *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2819 *	reserved.
2820 *
2821 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2822 *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2823 *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2824 *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2825 * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2826 *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2827 *
2828 * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2829 *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2830 *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2831 *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2832 *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2833 *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2834 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2835 *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2836 *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2837 *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2838 *
2839 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED: Flag attribute indicating that the link is
2840 *	disabled.
2841 *
2842 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA: Include BSS usage data, i.e.
2843 *	include BSSes that can only be used in restricted scenarios and/or
2844 *	cannot be used at all.
2845 *
2846 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK: Binary attribute specifying the downlink TID to
2847 *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2848 *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2849 *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2850 * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK: Binary attribute specifying the uplink TID to
2851 *      link mapping. The length is 8 * sizeof(u16). For each TID the link
2852 *      mapping is as defined in section 9.4.2.314 (TID-To-Link Mapping element)
2853 *      in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
2854 *
2855 * @NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU: flag attribute used with
2856 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE indicating the SPP A-MSDUs
2857 *	are used on this connection
2858 *
2859 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2860 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2861 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2862 */
2863enum nl80211_attrs {
2864/* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2865	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2866
2867	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2868	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2869
2870	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2871	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2872	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2873
2874	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2875
2876	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2877	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2878	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2879	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2880	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2881
2882	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2883	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2884	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2885	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2886
2887	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2888	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2889	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2890	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2891	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2892	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2893
2894	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2895
2896	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2897
2898	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2899	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2900	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2901	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2902
2903	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2904	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2905	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2906
2907	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2908
2909	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2910
2911	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2912	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2913
2914	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2915
2916	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2917
2918	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2919	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2920	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2921
2922	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2923
2924	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2925	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2926
2927	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2928
2929	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2930	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2931	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2932	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2933
2934	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2935	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2936
2937	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2938
2939	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2940	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2941	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2942	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2943
2944	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2945
2946	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2947	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2948
2949	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2950	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2951
2952	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2953
2954
2955	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2956	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2957	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2958	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2959
2960	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2961
2962	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2963
2964	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2965
2966	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2967
2968	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2969
2970	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2971
2972	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2973	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2974
2975	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2976	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2977	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2978	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2979
2980	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2981	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2982
2983	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2984
2985	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2986	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2987
2988	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2989
2990	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2991
2992	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2993
2994	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2995	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2996
2997	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2998
2999	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
3000
3001	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
3002
3003	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
3004
3005	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
3006
3007	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
3008
3009	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
3010
3011	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
3012
3013	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
3014
3015	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
3016
3017	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3018	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
3019
3020	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
3021	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
3022	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
3023
3024	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
3025	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
3026
3027	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
3028
3029	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
3030	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
3031
3032	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
3033
3034	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
3035
3036	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
3037
3038	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
3039
3040	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
3041
3042	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
3043
3044	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
3045	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
3046
3047	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
3048	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
3049
3050	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3051	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3052
3053	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3054
3055	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3056	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3057
3058	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3059
3060	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3061	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3062
3063	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3064
3065	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3066
3067	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3068	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3069
3070	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3071	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3072
3073	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3074
3075	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3076	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3077
3078	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3079
3080	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3081
3082	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3083	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3084	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3085	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3086	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3087
3088	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3089
3090	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3091
3092	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3093
3094	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3095
3096	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3097
3098	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3099
3100	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3101	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3102
3103	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3104
3105	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3106
3107	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3108
3109	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3110
3111	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3112
3113	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3114
3115	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3116
3117	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3118
3119	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3120
3121	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3122
3123	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3124	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3125	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3126
3127	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3128	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3129
3130	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3131
3132	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3133
3134	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3135
3136	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3137
3138	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3139
3140	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3141	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3142
3143	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3144	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3145
3146	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3147	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3148
3149	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3150	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3151
3152	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3153	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3154
3155	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3156	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3157
3158	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3159
3160	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3161
3162	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3163	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3164	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3165	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3166	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3167
3168	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3169
3170	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3171
3172	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3173
3174	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3175
3176	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3177	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3178
3179	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3180
3181	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3182	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3183	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3184	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3185
3186	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3187
3188	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3189	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3190
3191	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3192
3193	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3194
3195	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3196
3197	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3198	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3199
3200	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3201
3202	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3203
3204	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3205
3206	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3207	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3208	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3209
3210	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3211
3212	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3213
3214	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3215
3216	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3217
3218	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3219
3220	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3221
3222	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3223
3224	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3225
3226	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3227
3228	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3229	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3230	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3231	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3232
3233	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3234
3235	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3236
3237	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3238
3239	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3240
3241	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3242
3243	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3244	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3245
3246	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3247	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3248	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3249	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3250
3251	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3252
3253	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3254	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3255	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3256	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3257
3258	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3259	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3260
3261	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3262
3263	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3264
3265	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3266	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3267
3268	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3269
3270	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3271	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3272	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3273	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3274	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3275
3276	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3277
3278	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3279	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3280
3281	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3282	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3283	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3284
3285	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3286	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3287
3288	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3289	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3290
3291	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3292
3293	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3294	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3295	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3296	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3297
3298	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3299
3300	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3301
3302	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3303
3304	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3305
3306	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3307
3308	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3309	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3310	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3311
3312	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3313
3314	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3315
3316	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3317
3318	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3319	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3320
3321	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3322
3323	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3324
3325	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3326
3327	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3328
3329	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3330
3331	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3332	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3333
3334	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3335	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3336	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3337	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3338
3339	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3340
3341	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3342
3343	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3344
3345	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3346	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3347
3348	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3349
3350	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3351
3352	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3353
3354	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3355
3356	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3357
3358	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3359	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3360	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3361
3362	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3363	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3364
3365	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3366
3367	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3368
3369	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3370
3371	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3372
3373	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3374	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3375	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3376
3377	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3378
3379	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3380
3381	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3382	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3383
3384	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3385	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3386	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3387
3388	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3389
3390	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3391	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3392
3393	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3394
3395	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_DISABLED,
3396
3397	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_DUMP_INCLUDE_USE_DATA,
3398
3399	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_DLINK,
3400	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_TTLM_ULINK,
3401
3402	NL80211_ATTR_ASSOC_SPP_AMSDU,
3403
3404	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3405
3406	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3407	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3408	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3409};
3410
3411/* source-level API compatibility */
3412#define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3413#define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3414#define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3415#define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3416#define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3417#define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3418
3419/*
3420 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3421 * here
3422 */
3423#define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3424#define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3425#define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3426#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3427#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3428#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3429#define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3430#define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3431#define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3432#define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3433#define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3434#define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3435#define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3436#define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3437#define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3438#define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3439#define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3440#define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3441#define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3442#define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3443#define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3444
3445#define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3446
3447#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3448#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3449#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3450#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3451#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3452#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3453#define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3454#define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3455#define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3456#define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3457#define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3458
3459/*
3460 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3461 * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3462 */
3463#define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3464#define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3465#define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3466
3467#define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3468
3469/* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3470#define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3471
3472#define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3473
3474/**
3475 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3476 *
3477 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3478 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3479 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3480 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3481 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3482 *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3483 *	AP type interface.
3484 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3485 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3486 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3487 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3488 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3489 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3490 *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3491 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3492 *	commands to create and destroy one
3493 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3494 *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3495 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3496 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3497 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3498 *
3499 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3500 * to set the type of an interface.
3501 *
3502 */
3503enum nl80211_iftype {
3504	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3505	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3506	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3507	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3508	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3509	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3510	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3511	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3512	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3513	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3514	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3515	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3516	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3517
3518	/* keep last */
3519	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3520	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3521};
3522
3523/**
3524 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3525 *
3526 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3527 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3528 *
3529 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3530 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3531 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3532 *	with short barker preamble
3533 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3534 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3535 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3536 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3537 *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3538 *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3539 *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3540 *	as errors.)
3541 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3542 *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3543 *	previously added station into associated state
3544 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: station supports SPP A-MSDUs
3545 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3546 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3547 */
3548enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3549	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3550	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3551	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3552	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3553	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3554	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3555	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3556	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3557	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU,
3558
3559	/* keep last */
3560	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3561	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3562};
3563
3564/**
3565 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3566 *
3567 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3568 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3569 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3570 */
3571enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3572	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3573	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3574
3575	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3576};
3577
3578#define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3579
3580/**
3581 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3582 * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3583 * @set: which values to set them to
3584 *
3585 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3586 */
3587struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3588	__u32 mask;
3589	__u32 set;
3590} __attribute__((packed));
3591
3592/**
3593 * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3594 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3595 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3596 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3597 */
3598enum nl80211_he_gi {
3599	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3600	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3601	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3602};
3603
3604/**
3605 * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3606 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
3607 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
3608 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
3609 */
3610enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3611	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3612	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3613	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3614};
3615
3616/**
3617 * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3618 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3619 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3620 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3621 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3622 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3623 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3624 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3625 */
3626enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3627	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3628	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3629	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3630	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3631	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3632	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3633	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3634};
3635
3636/**
3637 * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3638 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3639 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3640 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3641 */
3642enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3643	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3644	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3645	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3646};
3647
3648/**
3649 * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3650 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3651 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3652 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3653 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3654 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3655 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3656 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3657 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3658 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3659 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3660 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3661 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3662 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3663 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3664 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3665 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3666 */
3667enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3668	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3669	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3670	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3671	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3672	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3673	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3674	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3675	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3676	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3677	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3678	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3679	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3680	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3681	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3682	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3683	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3684};
3685
3686/**
3687 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3688 *
3689 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3690 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3691 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3692 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3693 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3694 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3695 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3696 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3697 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3698 *
3699 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3700 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3701 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3702 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3703 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3704 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3705 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3706 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3707 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3708 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3709 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3710 *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3711 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3712 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3713 *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3714 *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3715 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3716 *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3717 *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3718 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3719 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3720 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3721 *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3722 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3723 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3724 *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3725 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3726 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3727 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3728 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3729 *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3730 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3731 *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3732 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS: S1G MCS index (u8, 0-10)
3733 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS: S1G NSS value (u8, 1-4)
3734 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH: 1 MHz S1G rate
3735 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH: 2 MHz S1G rate
3736 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH: 4 MHz S1G rate
3737 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH: 8 MHz S1G rate
3738 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH: 16 MHz S1G rate
3739 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3740 */
3741enum nl80211_rate_info {
3742	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3743	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3744	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3745	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3746	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3747	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3748	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3749	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3750	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3751	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3752	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3753	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3754	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3755	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3756	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3757	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3758	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3759	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3760	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3761	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3762	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3763	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3764	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3765	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_MCS,
3766	NL80211_RATE_INFO_S1G_NSS,
3767	NL80211_RATE_INFO_1_MHZ_WIDTH,
3768	NL80211_RATE_INFO_2_MHZ_WIDTH,
3769	NL80211_RATE_INFO_4_MHZ_WIDTH,
3770	NL80211_RATE_INFO_8_MHZ_WIDTH,
3771	NL80211_RATE_INFO_16_MHZ_WIDTH,
3772
3773	/* keep last */
3774	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3775	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3776};
3777
3778/**
3779 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3780 *
3781 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3782 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3783 *
3784 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3785 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3786 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3787 *	(flag)
3788 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3789 *	(flag)
3790 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3791 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3792 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3793 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3794 */
3795enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3796	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3797	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3798	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3799	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3800	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3801	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3802
3803	/* keep last */
3804	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3805	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3806};
3807
3808/**
3809 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3810 *
3811 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3812 * when getting information about a station.
3813 *
3814 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3815 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3816 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3817 *	(u32, from this station)
3818 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3819 *	(u32, to this station)
3820 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3821 *	(u64, from this station)
3822 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3823 *	(u64, to this station)
3824 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3825 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3826 * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3827 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3828 *	(u32, from this station)
3829 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3830 *	(u32, to this station)
3831 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3832 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3833 *	(u32, to this station)
3834 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3835 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3836 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3837 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3838 *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3839 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3840 *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3841 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3842 *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3843 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3844 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3845 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3846 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3847 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3848 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3849 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3850 *	non-peer STA
3851 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3852 *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3853 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3854 *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3855 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3856 *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3857 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3858 *	(u64)
3859 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3860 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3861 *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3862 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3863 *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3864 *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3865 *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3866 *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3867 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3868 *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3869 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3870 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3871 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3872 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3873 *	(u32, from this station)
3874 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3875 *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3876 *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3877 *	might not be fully accurate.
3878 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3879 *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3880 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3881 *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3882 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3883 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3884 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3885 *	of STA's association
3886 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3887 *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3888 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3889 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3890 */
3891enum nl80211_sta_info {
3892	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3893	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3894	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3895	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3896	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3897	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3898	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3899	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3900	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3901	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3902	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3903	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3904	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3905	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3906	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3907	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3908	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3909	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3910	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3911	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3912	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3913	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3914	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3915	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3916	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3917	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3918	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3919	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3920	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3921	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3922	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3923	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3924	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3925	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3926	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3927	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3928	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3929	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3930	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3931	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3932	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3933	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3934	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3935	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3936
3937	/* keep last */
3938	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3939	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3940};
3941
3942/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3943#define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3944
3945
3946/**
3947 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3948 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3949 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3950 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3951 *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3952 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3953 *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3954 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3955 *	MSDUs (u64)
3956 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3957 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3958 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3959 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3960 */
3961enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3962	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3963	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3964	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3965	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3966	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3967	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3968	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3969
3970	/* keep last */
3971	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3972	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3973};
3974
3975/**
3976 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3977 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3978 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3979 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3980 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3981 *      backlogged
3982 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3983 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3984 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3985 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3986 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3987 *      (only for per-phy stats)
3988 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3989 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3990 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3991 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3992 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3993 */
3994enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3995	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3996	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3997	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3998	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3999	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
4000	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
4001	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
4002	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
4003	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
4004	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
4005	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
4006	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
4007
4008	/* keep last */
4009	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
4010	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
4011};
4012
4013/**
4014 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
4015 *
4016 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
4017 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
4018 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
4019 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
4020 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
4021 */
4022enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
4023	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
4024	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
4025	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
4026	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
4027	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
4028};
4029
4030/**
4031 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
4032 *
4033 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
4034 * information about a mesh path.
4035 *
4036 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4037 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
4038 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
4039 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
4040 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
4041 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
4042 * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
4043 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
4044 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
4045 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
4046 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
4047 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
4048 *	currently defined
4049 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4050 */
4051enum nl80211_mpath_info {
4052	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
4053	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
4054	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
4055	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
4056	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
4057	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
4058	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4059	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
4060	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
4061	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
4062
4063	/* keep last */
4064	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4065	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4066};
4067
4068/**
4069 * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
4070 *
4071 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4072 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
4073 *     for each interface type that supports the band data
4074 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
4075 *     capabilities IE
4076 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4077 *     capabilities IE
4078 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4079 *     capabilities IE
4080 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4081 *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4082 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4083 *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4084 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4085 *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4086 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4087 *	capabilities element
4088 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4089 *	capabilities element
4090 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4091 *	capabilities element
4092 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4093 *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4094 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4095 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4096 */
4097enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4098	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4099
4100	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4101	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4102	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4103	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4104	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4105	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4106	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4107	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4108	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4109	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4110	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4111
4112	/* keep last */
4113	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4114	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4115};
4116
4117/**
4118 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4119 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4120 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4121 *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4122 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4123 *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4124 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4125 *	defined in 802.11n
4126 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4127 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4128 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4129 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4130 *	defined in 802.11ac
4131 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4132 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4133 *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4134 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4135 *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4136 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4137 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4138 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4139 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4140 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4141 *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4142 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4143 *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4144 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4145 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4146 */
4147enum nl80211_band_attr {
4148	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4149	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4150	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4151
4152	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4153	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4154	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4155	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4156
4157	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4158	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4159	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4160
4161	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4162	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4163
4164	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4165	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4166
4167	/* keep last */
4168	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4169	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4170};
4171
4172#define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4173
4174/**
4175 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4176 *
4177 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4178 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4179 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4180 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4181 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4182 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4183 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4184 */
4185enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4186	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4187	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4188	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4189	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4190	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4191
4192	/* keep last */
4193	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4194	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4195};
4196
4197/**
4198 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4199 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4200 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4201 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4202 *	regulatory domain.
4203 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4204 * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4205 * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4206 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4207 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4208 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4209 *	(100 * dBm).
4210 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4211 *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4212 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in milliseconds for how long
4213 *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4214 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4215 *	channel as the control channel
4216 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4217 *	channel as the control channel
4218 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4219 *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4220 *	this includes 80+80 channels
4221 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4222 *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4223 *	isn't possible
4224 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4225 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4226 *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4227 *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4228 *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4229 *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4230 *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4231 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4232 *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4233 *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4234 *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4235 *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4236 *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4237 *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4238 *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4239 *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4240 *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4241 *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4242 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4243 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4244 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4245 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4246 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4247 *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4248 *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4249 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4250 *	in current regulatory domain.
4251 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4252 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4253 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4254 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4255 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4256 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4257 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4258 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4259 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4260 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4261 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4262 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4263 *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4264 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4265 *	in current regulatory domain.
4266 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) that
4267 *	is allowed on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4268 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is
4269 *	allowed for peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control
4270 *	of a DFS master which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01
4271 *	Section B.3). Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4272 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP
4273 *	not allowed using this channel
4274 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP
4275 *	not allowed using this channel
4276 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used in monitor
4277 *	mode despite other (regulatory) restrictions, even if the channel is
4278 *	otherwise completely disabled.
4279 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4280 *	currently defined
4281 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4282 *
4283 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4284 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4285 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4286 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4287 */
4288enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4289	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4290	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4291	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4292	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4293	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4294	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4295	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4296	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4297	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4298	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4299	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4300	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4301	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4302	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4303	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4304	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4305	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4306	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4307	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4308	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4309	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4310	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4311	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4312	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4313	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4314	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4315	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4316	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4317	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PSD,
4318	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CONCURRENT,
4319	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT,
4320	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT,
4321	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_CAN_MONITOR,
4322
4323	/* keep last */
4324	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4325	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4326};
4327
4328#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4329#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4330#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4331#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4332#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4333					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4334#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT \
4335	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4336#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT \
4337	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4338
4339/**
4340 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4341 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4342 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4343 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4344 *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4345 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4346 *	currently defined
4347 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4348 */
4349enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4350	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4351	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4352	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4353
4354	/* keep last */
4355	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4356	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4357};
4358
4359/**
4360 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4361 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4362 * 	regulatory domain.
4363 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4364 * 	regulatory domain.
4365 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4366 * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4367 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4368 * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4369 * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4370 *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4371 *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4372 *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4373 *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4374 */
4375enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4376	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4377	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4378	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4379	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4380};
4381
4382/**
4383 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4384 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4385 *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4386 *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4387 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4388 * 	domain.
4389 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4390 * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4391 * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4392 * 	them to be applied.
4393 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4394 *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4395 *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4396 *	domain request to be processed.
4397 */
4398enum nl80211_reg_type {
4399	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4400	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4401	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4402	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4403};
4404
4405/**
4406 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4407 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4408 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4409 * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4410 * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4411 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4412 * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4413 * 	band edge.
4414 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4415 * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4416 * 	band edge.
4417 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4418 *	frequency range, in KHz.
4419 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4420 * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4421 * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4422 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4423 * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4424 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4425 *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4426 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD: power spectral density (in dBm).
4427 *	This could be negative.
4428 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4429 *	currently defined
4430 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4431 */
4432enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4433	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4434	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4435
4436	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4437	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4438	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4439
4440	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4441	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4442
4443	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4444
4445	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_PSD,
4446
4447	/* keep last */
4448	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4449	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4450};
4451
4452/**
4453 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4454 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4455 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4456 *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4457 *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4458 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4459 *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4460 *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4461 *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4462 *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4463 *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4464 *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4465 *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4466 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4467 *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4468 *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4469 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4470 *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4471 *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4472 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4473 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4474 *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4475 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Obsolete
4476 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4477 *	attribute number currently defined
4478 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4479 */
4480enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4481	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4482
4483	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4484	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4485	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4486	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4487	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4488	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI, /* obsolete */
4489
4490	/* keep last */
4491	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4492	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4493		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4494};
4495
4496/* only for backward compatibility */
4497#define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4498
4499/**
4500 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4501 *
4502 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4503 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4504 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4505 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4506 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4507 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4508 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4509 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4510 * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4511 * 	beaconing.
4512 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4513 *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4514 *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4515 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4516 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4517 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4518 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4519 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4520 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4521 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4522 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT: EHT operation not allowed
4523 * @NL80211_RRF_PSD: Ruleset has power spectral density value
4524 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT: Operation on this channel is allowed for
4525	peer-to-peer or adhoc communication under the control of a DFS master
4526	which operates on the same channel (FCC-594280 D01 Section B.3).
4527	Should be used together with %NL80211_RRF_DFS only.
4528 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection to VLP AP not allowed
4529 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection to AFC AP not allowed
4530 */
4531enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4532	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4533	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4534	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4535	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4536	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4537	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4538	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4539	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4540	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4541	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4542	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4543	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4544	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4545	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4546	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4547	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4548	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
4549	NL80211_RRF_NO_EHT		= 1<<19,
4550	NL80211_RRF_PSD			= 1<<20,
4551	NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT	= 1<<21,
4552	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT	= 1<<22,
4553	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT	= 1<<23,
4554};
4555
4556#define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4557#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4558#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4559#define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4560					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4561#define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4562#define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_VLP_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT
4563#define NL80211_RRF_NO_UHB_AFC_CLIENT	NL80211_RRF_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT
4564
4565/* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4566#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4567
4568/**
4569 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4570 *
4571 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4572 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4573 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4574 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4575 */
4576enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4577	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4578	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4579	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4580	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4581};
4582
4583/**
4584 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4585 *
4586 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4587 *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4588 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4589 *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4590 *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4591 *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4592 *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4593 *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4594 *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4595 *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4596 *	supported feature.
4597 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4598 *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4599 */
4600enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4601	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4602	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4603	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4604};
4605
4606/**
4607 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4608 *
4609 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4610 * when getting information about a survey.
4611 *
4612 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4613 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4614 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4615 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4616 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4617 *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4618 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4619 *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4620 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4621 *	channel was sensed busy
4622 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4623 *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4624 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4625 *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4626 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4627 *	(on this channel or globally)
4628 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4629 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4630 *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4631 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4632 *	currently defined
4633 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4634 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4635 */
4636enum nl80211_survey_info {
4637	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4638	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4639	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4640	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4641	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4642	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4643	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4644	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4645	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4646	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4647	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4648	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4649	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4650
4651	/* keep last */
4652	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4653	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4654};
4655
4656/* keep old names for compatibility */
4657#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4658#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4659#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4660#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4661#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4662
4663/**
4664 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4665 *
4666 * Monitor configuration flags.
4667 *
4668 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4669 *
4670 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4671 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4672 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4673 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4674 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4675 *	overrides all other flags.
4676 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4677 *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4678 *
4679 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4680 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4681 */
4682enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4683	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4684	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4685	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4686	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4687	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4688	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4689	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4690
4691	/* keep last */
4692	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4693	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4694};
4695
4696/**
4697 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4698 *
4699 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4700 *	not known or has not been set yet.
4701 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4702 *	in Awake state all the time.
4703 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4704 *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4705 *	neighbor's beacons.
4706 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4707 *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4708 *	for neighbor's beacons.
4709 *
4710 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4711 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4712 */
4713
4714enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4715	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4716	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4717	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4718	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4719
4720	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4721	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4722};
4723
4724/**
4725 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4726 *
4727 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4728 * active.
4729 *
4730 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4731 *
4732 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4733 *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4734 *
4735 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4736 *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4737 *
4738 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4739 *	millisecond units
4740 *
4741 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4742 *	on this mesh interface
4743 *
4744 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4745 *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4746 *	mesh
4747 *
4748 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4749 *	point.
4750 *
4751 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4752 *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4753 *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4754 *	set.
4755 *
4756 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4757 *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4758 *	target)
4759 *
4760 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4761 *	(in milliseconds)
4762 *
4763 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4764 *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4765 *
4766 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4767 *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4768 *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4769 *
4770 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4771 *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4772 *	reference element
4773 *
4774 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4775 *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4776 *	mesh
4777 *
4778 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4779 *
4780 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4781 *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4782 *
4783 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4784 *	root announcements are transmitted.
4785 *
4786 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4787 *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4788 *	Announcement frames.
4789 *
4790 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4791 *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4792 *	PERR element.
4793 *
4794 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4795 *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4796 *
4797 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4798 *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4799 *	a peer link.
4800 *
4801 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4802 *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4803 *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4804 *
4805 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4806 *
4807 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4808 *
4809 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4810 *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4811 *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4812 *
4813 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4814 *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4815 *
4816 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4817 *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4818 *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4819 *
4820 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4821 *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4822 *
4823 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4824 *
4825 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4826 *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4827 *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4828 *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4829 *
4830 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4831 *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4832 *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4833 *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4834 *
4835 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4836 *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4837 *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4838 *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4839 *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4840 *
4841 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4842 *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4843 *	in the mesh formation field.
4844 *
4845 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4846 */
4847enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4848	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4849	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4850	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4851	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4852	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4853	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4854	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4855	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4856	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4857	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4858	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4859	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4860	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4861	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4862	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4863	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4864	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4865	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4866	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4867	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4868	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4869	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4870	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4871	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4872	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4873	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4874	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4875	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4876	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4877	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4878	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4879	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4880
4881	/* keep last */
4882	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4883	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4884};
4885
4886/**
4887 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4888 *
4889 * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4890 * changed while the mesh is active.
4891 *
4892 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4893 *
4894 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4895 *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4896 *	default HWMP.
4897 *
4898 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4899 *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4900 *	metric.
4901 *
4902 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4903 *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4904 *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4905 *	metrics in use.
4906 *
4907 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4908 *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4909 *
4910 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4911 *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4912 *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4913 *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4914 *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4915 *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4916 *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4917 *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4918 *	userspace daemon.
4919 *
4920 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4921 *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4922 *	neighbor offset synchronization
4923 *
4924 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4925 *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4926 *
4927 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4928 *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4929 *	Default is no authentication method required.
4930 *
4931 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4932 *
4933 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4934 */
4935enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4936	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4937	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4938	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4939	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4940	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4941	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4942	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4943	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4944	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4945
4946	/* keep last */
4947	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4948	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4949};
4950
4951/**
4952 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4953 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4954 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4955 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4956 *	disabled
4957 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4958 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4959 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4960 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4961 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4962 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4963 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4964 */
4965enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4966	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4967	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4968	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4969	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4970	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4971	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4972
4973	/* keep last */
4974	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4975	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4976};
4977
4978enum nl80211_ac {
4979	NL80211_AC_VO,
4980	NL80211_AC_VI,
4981	NL80211_AC_BE,
4982	NL80211_AC_BK,
4983	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4984};
4985
4986/* backward compat */
4987#define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4988#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4989#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4990#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4991#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4992
4993/**
4994 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4995 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4996 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4997 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4998 *	below the control channel
4999 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
5000 *	above the control channel
5001 */
5002enum nl80211_channel_type {
5003	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
5004	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
5005	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
5006	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
5007};
5008
5009/**
5010 * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
5011 *
5012 * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
5013 *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
5014 *
5015 * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
5016 * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
5017 *
5018 * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
5019 *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
5020 * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
5021 *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
5022 *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
5023 */
5024enum nl80211_key_mode {
5025	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
5026	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
5027	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
5028};
5029
5030/**
5031 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
5032 *
5033 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
5034 * attribute.
5035 *
5036 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
5037 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
5038 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5039 *	attribute must be provided as well
5040 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5041 *	attribute must be provided as well
5042 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5043 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
5044 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5045 *	attribute must be provided as well
5046 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
5047 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
5048 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
5049 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
5050 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
5051 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
5052 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
5053 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
5054 *	attribute must be provided as well
5055 */
5056enum nl80211_chan_width {
5057	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
5058	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5059	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
5060	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
5061	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
5062	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
5063	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5064	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5065	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5066	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5067	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
5068	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
5069	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
5070	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
5071};
5072
5073/**
5074 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
5075 *
5076 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
5077 *
5078 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
5079 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
5080 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
5081 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
5082 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
5083 */
5084enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
5085	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
5086	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
5087	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
5088	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
5089	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
5090};
5091
5092/**
5093 * enum nl80211_bss_use_for - bitmap indicating possible BSS use
5094 * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL: Use this BSS for normal "connection",
5095 *	including IBSS/MBSS depending on the type.
5096 * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK: This BSS can be used as a link in an
5097 *	MLO connection. Note that for an MLO connection, all links including
5098 *	the assoc link must have this flag set, and the assoc link must
5099 *	additionally have %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL set.
5100 */
5101enum nl80211_bss_use_for {
5102	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL = 1 << 0,
5103	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_MLD_LINK = 1 << 1,
5104};
5105
5106/**
5107 * enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons - reason(s) connection to a
5108 *	BSS isn't possible
5109 * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: NSTR nonprimary links aren't
5110 *	supported by the device, and this BSS entry represents one.
5111 * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH: STA is not supporting
5112 *	the AP power type (SP, VLP, AP) that the AP uses.
5113 */
5114enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons {
5115	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_NSTR_NONPRIMARY	= 1 << 0,
5116	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH	= 1 << 1,
5117};
5118
5119#define NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_UHB_PWR_MISMATCH \
5120	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_6GHZ_PWR_MISMATCH
5121
5122/**
5123 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
5124 *
5125 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
5126 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
5127 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
5128 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
5129 *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
5130 *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
5131 *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
5132 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
5133 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
5134 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
5135 *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
5136 *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
5137 *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
5138 *	they are from a Beacon frame.
5139 *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5140 *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5141 *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5142 *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5143 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5144 *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5145 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5146 *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5147 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5148 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5149 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5150 *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5151 *	yet been received
5152 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5153 *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width) - No longer used!
5154 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5155 *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5156 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5157 *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5158 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5159 *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5160 *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5161 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5162 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5163 *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5164 *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5165 *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5166 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5167 *	is set.
5168 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5169 *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5170 *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5171 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5172 * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5173 * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5174 * @NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR: u32 bitmap attribute indicating what the BSS can be
5175 *	used for, see &enum nl80211_bss_use_for.
5176 * @NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS: Indicates the reason that this BSS cannot
5177 *	be used for all or some of the possible uses by the device reporting it,
5178 *	even though its presence was detected.
5179 *	This is a u64 attribute containing a bitmap of values from
5180 *	&enum nl80211_cannot_use_reasons, note that the attribute may be missing
5181 *	if no reasons are specified.
5182 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5183 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5184 */
5185enum nl80211_bss {
5186	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5187	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5188	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5189	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5190	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5191	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5192	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5193	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5194	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5195	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5196	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5197	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5198	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5199	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5200	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5201	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5202	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5203	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5204	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5205	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5206	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5207	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5208	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5209	NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR,
5210	NL80211_BSS_CANNOT_USE_REASONS,
5211
5212	/* keep last */
5213	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5214	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5215};
5216
5217/**
5218 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5219 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5220 *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5221 *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5222 *	a given BSS.
5223 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5224 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5225 *
5226 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5227 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5228 */
5229enum nl80211_bss_status {
5230	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5231	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5232	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5233};
5234
5235/**
5236 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5237 *
5238 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5239 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5240 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5241 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5242 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5243 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5244 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5245 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5246 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5247 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5248 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5249 *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5250 *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5251 */
5252enum nl80211_auth_type {
5253	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5254	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5255	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5256	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5257	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5258	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5259	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5260	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5261
5262	/* keep last */
5263	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5264	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5265	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5266};
5267
5268/**
5269 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5270 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5271 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5272 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5273 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5274 */
5275enum nl80211_key_type {
5276	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5277	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5278	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5279
5280	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5281};
5282
5283/**
5284 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5285 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5286 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5287 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5288 */
5289enum nl80211_mfp {
5290	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5291	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5292	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5293};
5294
5295enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5296	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5297	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5298	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5299};
5300
5301/**
5302 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5303 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5304 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5305 *	unicast key
5306 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5307 *	multicast key
5308 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5309 */
5310enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5311	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5312	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5313	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5314
5315	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5316};
5317
5318/**
5319 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5320 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5321 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5322 *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5323 *	keys
5324 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5325 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5326 *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5327 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5328 *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5329 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5330 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5331 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5332 *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5333 *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5334 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5335 *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5336 *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5337 * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5338 *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5339 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5340 *
5341 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5342 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5343 */
5344enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5345	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5346	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5347	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5348	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5349	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5350	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5351	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5352	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5353	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5354	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5355	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5356
5357	/* keep last */
5358	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5359	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5360};
5361
5362/**
5363 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5364 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5365 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5366 *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5367 *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5368 *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5369 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5370 *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5371 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5372 *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5373 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5374 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5375 *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5376 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5377 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5378 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5379 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5380 */
5381enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5382	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5383	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5384	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5385	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5386	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5387	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5388	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5389	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5390
5391	/* keep last */
5392	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5393	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5394};
5395
5396#define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5397#define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5398
5399/**
5400 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5401 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5402 */
5403struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5404	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5405};
5406
5407#define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5408/**
5409 * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5410 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5411 */
5412struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5413	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5414};
5415
5416enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5417	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5418	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5419	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5420};
5421
5422/**
5423 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5424 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5425 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5426 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5427 * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5428 * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5429 * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5430 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5431 *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5432 */
5433enum nl80211_band {
5434	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5435	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5436	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5437	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5438	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5439	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5440
5441	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5442};
5443
5444/**
5445 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5446 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5447 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5448 */
5449enum nl80211_ps_state {
5450	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5451	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5452};
5453
5454/**
5455 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5456 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5457 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5458 *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5459 *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5460 *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5461 *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5462 *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5463 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5464 *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5465 *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5466 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5467 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5468 *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5469 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5470 *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5471 *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5472 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5473 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5474 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5475 *	checked.
5476 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5477 *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5478 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5479 *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5480 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5481 *	loss event
5482 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5483 *	RSSI threshold event.
5484 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5485 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5486 */
5487enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5488	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5489	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5490	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5491	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5492	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5493	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5494	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5495	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5496	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5497	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5498
5499	/* keep last */
5500	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5501	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5502};
5503
5504/**
5505 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5506 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5507 *      configured threshold
5508 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5509 *      configured threshold
5510 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5511 */
5512enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5513	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5514	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5515	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5516};
5517
5518
5519/**
5520 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5521 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5522 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5523 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5524 */
5525enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5526	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5527	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5528	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5529};
5530
5531/**
5532 * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5533 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5534 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5535 */
5536enum nl80211_tid_config {
5537	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5538	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5539};
5540
5541/* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5542 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5543 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5544 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5545 */
5546enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5547	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5548	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5549	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5550};
5551
5552/* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5553 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5554 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5555 *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5556 *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5557 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5558 *	per peer instead.
5559 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribute, if set indicates
5560 *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5561 *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5562 *	should be left untouched.
5563 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5564 *	Its type is u16.
5565 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5566 *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5567 *	Its type is u8.
5568 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5569 *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5570 *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5571 *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5572 *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5573 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5574 *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5575 *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5576 *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5577 *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5578 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5579 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5580 *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5581 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5582 *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5583 *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5584 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5585 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5586 *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5587 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5588 *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5589 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5590 *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5591 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5592 *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5593 *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5594 *	station.
5595 */
5596enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5597	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5598	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5599	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5600	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5601	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5602	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5603	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5604	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5605	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5606	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5607	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5608	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5609	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5610	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5611
5612	/* keep last */
5613	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5614	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5615};
5616
5617/**
5618 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5619 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5620 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5621 *	a zero bit are ignored
5622 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5623 *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5624 *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5625 *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5626 *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5627 *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5628 *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5629 *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5630 *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5631 *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5632 *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5633 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5634 *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5635 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5636 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5637 */
5638enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5639	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5640	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5641	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5642	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5643
5644	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5645	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5646};
5647
5648/**
5649 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5650 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5651 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5652 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5653 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5654 *
5655 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5656 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5657 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5658 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5659 * by the kernel to userspace.
5660 */
5661struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5662	__u32 max_patterns;
5663	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5664	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5665	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5666} __attribute__((packed));
5667
5668/* only for backward compatibility */
5669#define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5670#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5671#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5672#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5673#define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5674#define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5675#define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5676
5677/**
5678 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5679 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5680 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5681 *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5682 *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5683 *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5684 *	any others are even supported by the device.
5685 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5686 *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5687 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5688 *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5689 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5690 *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5691 *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5692 *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5693 *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5694 *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5695 *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5696 *
5697 *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5698 *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5699 *
5700 *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5701 *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5702 *	to the kernel when configuring.
5703 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5704 *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5705 *	by the device (flag)
5706 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5707 *	done by the device) (flag)
5708 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5709 *	packet (flag)
5710 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5711 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5712 *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5713 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5714 *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5715 *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5716 *	attribute contains the original length.
5717 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5718 *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5719 *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5720 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5721 *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5722 *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5723 *	contains the original length.
5724 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5725 *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5726 *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5727 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5728 *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5729 *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5730 *	the TCP connection.
5731 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5732 *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5733 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5734 *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5735 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5736 *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5737 *	service
5738 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5739 *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5740 *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5741 *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5742 *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5743 *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5744 *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5745 *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5746 *	supported by the driver (u32).
5747 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5748 *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5749 *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5750 *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5751 *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5752 *	occurred.
5753 *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5754 *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5755 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5756 *	these attributes must be present.  If
5757 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5758 *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5759 *	channel.
5760 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC: For wakeup reporting only.
5761 *	Wake up happened due to unprotected deauth or disassoc frame in MFP.
5762 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5763 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5764 *
5765 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5766 * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5767 */
5768enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5769	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5770	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5771	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5772	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5773	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5774	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5775	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5776	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5777	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5778	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5779	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5780	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5781	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5782	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5783	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5784	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5785	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5786	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5787	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5788	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5789	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_UNPROTECTED_DEAUTH_DISASSOC,
5790
5791	/* keep last */
5792	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5793	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5794};
5795
5796/**
5797 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5798 *
5799 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5800 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5801 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5802 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5803 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5804 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5805 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5806 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5807 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5808 *
5809 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5810 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5811 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5812 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5813 * also woken up.
5814 *
5815 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5816 * response packets might not go through correctly.
5817 */
5818
5819/**
5820 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5821 * @start: starting value
5822 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5823 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5824 *
5825 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5826 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5827 * in little endian.
5828 */
5829struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5830	__u32 start, offset, len;
5831};
5832
5833/**
5834 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5835 * @offset: offset of token in packet
5836 * @len: length of each token
5837 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5838 *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5839 */
5840struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5841	__u32 offset, len;
5842	__u8 token_stream[];
5843};
5844
5845/**
5846 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5847 * @min_len: minimum token length
5848 * @max_len: maximum token length
5849 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5850 */
5851struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5852	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5853};
5854
5855/**
5856 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5857 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5858 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5859 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5860 *	(in network byte order)
5861 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5862 *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5863 *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5864 *	might require ARP querying.
5865 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5866 *	socket and port will be allocated
5867 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5868 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5869 *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5870 *	of the data payload.
5871 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5872 *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5873 *	advertising it is just a flag
5874 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5875 *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5876 *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5877 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5878 *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5879 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5880 *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5881 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5882 *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5883 *	but on the TCP payload only.
5884 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5885 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5886 */
5887enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5888	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5889	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5890	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5891	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5892	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5893	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5894	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5895	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5896	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5897	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5898	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5899	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5900
5901	/* keep last */
5902	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5903	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5904};
5905
5906/**
5907 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5908 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5909 * @pat: packet pattern support information
5910 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5911 *
5912 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5913 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5914 */
5915struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5916	__u32 max_rules;
5917	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5918	__u32 max_delay;
5919} __attribute__((packed));
5920
5921/**
5922 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5923 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5924 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5925 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5926 *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5927 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5928 *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5929 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5930 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5931 */
5932enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5933	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5934	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5935	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5936	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5937
5938	/* keep last */
5939	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5940	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5941};
5942
5943/**
5944 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5945 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5946 *	in a rule are matched.
5947 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5948 *	in a rule are not matched.
5949 */
5950enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5951	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5952	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5953};
5954
5955/**
5956 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5957 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5958 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5959 *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5960 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5961 *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5962 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5963 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5964 */
5965enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5966	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5967	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5968	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5969
5970	/* keep last */
5971	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5972	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5973};
5974
5975/**
5976 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5977 *
5978 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5979 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5980 *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5981 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5982 *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5983 *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5984 *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5985 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5986 *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5987 *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5988 *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5989 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5990 *	different channels may be used within this group.
5991 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5992 *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5993 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5994 *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5995 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5996 *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5997 *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5998 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5999 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
6000 *
6001 * Examples:
6002 *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
6003 *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
6004 *
6005 *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
6006 *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
6007 *
6008 *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
6009 *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
6010 *
6011 *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
6012 *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
6013 *
6014 * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
6015 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
6016 * that any of these groups must match.
6017 *
6018 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
6019 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
6020 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
6021 * interface type, the following group always exists:
6022 *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
6023 */
6024enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
6025	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
6026	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
6027	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
6028	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
6029	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
6030	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
6031	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
6032	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
6033
6034	/* keep last */
6035	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
6036	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
6037};
6038
6039
6040/**
6041 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
6042 *
6043 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
6044 *	state of non-existent mesh peer links
6045 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
6046 *	this mesh peer
6047 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
6048 *	from this mesh peer
6049 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
6050 *	received from this mesh peer
6051 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
6052 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
6053 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
6054 *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
6055 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
6056 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
6057 */
6058enum nl80211_plink_state {
6059	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
6060	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
6061	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
6062	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
6063	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
6064	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
6065	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
6066
6067	/* keep last */
6068	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
6069	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
6070};
6071
6072/**
6073 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
6074 *
6075 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
6076 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
6077 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
6078 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
6079 */
6080enum plink_actions {
6081	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
6082	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
6083	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
6084
6085	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
6086};
6087
6088
6089#define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
6090#define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
6091#define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
6092#define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
6093#define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
6094#define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
6095
6096/**
6097 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
6098 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6099 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
6100 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
6101 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
6102 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
6103 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
6104 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
6105 */
6106enum nl80211_rekey_data {
6107	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
6108	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
6109	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
6110	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
6111	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
6112
6113	/* keep last */
6114	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
6115	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
6116};
6117
6118/**
6119 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
6120 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
6121 *	Beacon frames)
6122 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
6123 *	in Beacon frames
6124 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
6125 *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
6126 */
6127enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
6128	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
6129	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
6130	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
6131};
6132
6133/**
6134 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
6135 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
6136 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
6137 *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
6138 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
6139 *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
6140 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
6141 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
6142 */
6143enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
6144	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
6145	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
6146	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
6147
6148	/* keep last */
6149	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
6150	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
6151};
6152
6153/**
6154 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6155 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6156 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6157 *	priority)
6158 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6159 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6160 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6161 *	(internal)
6162 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6163 *	(internal)
6164 */
6165enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6166	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6167	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6168	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6169	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6170
6171	/* keep last */
6172	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6173	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6174};
6175
6176/**
6177 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6178 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6179 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6180 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6181 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6182 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6183 */
6184enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6185	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6186	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6187	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6188	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6189	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6190};
6191
6192/**
6193 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6194 * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6195 *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6196 *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6197 */
6198enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6199	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6200};
6201
6202/**
6203 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6204 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6205 *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6206 *	socket option.
6207 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6208 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6209 *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6210 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6211 *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6212 *	cellular base stations.
6213 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6214 *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6215 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6216 *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6217 *	mode
6218 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6219 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6220 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6221 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6222 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6223 *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6224 *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6225 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6226 *	setting
6227 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6228 *	powersave
6229 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6230 *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6231 *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6232 *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6233 *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6234 *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6235 *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6236 *	states using station flags.
6237 *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6238 *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6239 *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6240 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6241 *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6242 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6243 *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6244 *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6245 *	still generated by the driver.
6246 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6247 *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6248 *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6249 *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6250 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6251 *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6252 *	lifetime of a BSS.
6253 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6254 *	Set IE to probe requests.
6255 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6256 *	to probe requests.
6257 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6258 *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6259 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6260 *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6261 *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6262 *	Measurement Report action frame.
6263 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6264 *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6265 *	to enable dynack.
6266 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6267 *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6268 *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6269 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6270 *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6271 *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6272 *	rts/cts handshake.
6273 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6274 *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6275 *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6276 *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6277 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6278 *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6279 *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6280 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6281 *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6282 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6283 *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6284 *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6285 *	address mask/value will be used.
6286 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6287 *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6288 *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6289 *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6290 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6291 *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6292 *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6293 *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6294 */
6295enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6296	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6297	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6298	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6299	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6300	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6301	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6302	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6303	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6304	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6305	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6306	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6307	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6308	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6309	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6310	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6311	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6312	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6313	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6314	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6315	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6316	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6317	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6318	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6319	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6320	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6321	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6322	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6323	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6324	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6325	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6326	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6327	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6328};
6329
6330/**
6331 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6332 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6333 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6334 *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6335 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6336 *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6337 *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertised.
6338 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6339 *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6340 *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6341 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6342 *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6343 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6344 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6345 *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6346 *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6347 *	(if available).
6348 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6349 *	time the last beacon/probe was received. For a non-MLO connection, the
6350 *	time is the TSF of the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is
6351 *	connected to (if available). For an MLO connection, the time is the TSF
6352 *	of the BSS corresponding with link ID specified in the scan request (if
6353 *	specified).
6354 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6355 *	channel dwell time.
6356 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6357 *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non-HT/VHT) rate.
6358 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6359 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6360 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6361 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6362 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6363 *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6364 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6365 *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6366 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6367 *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6368 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6369 *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6370 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6371 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6372 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6373 *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6374 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6375 *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6376 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6377 *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6378 *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6379 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6380 *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6381 *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6382 *	be supported.
6383 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6384 *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6385 *	actual dwell time.
6386 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6387 *	response
6388 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6389 *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6390 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6391 *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6392 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6393 *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6394 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6395 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6396 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6397 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6398 *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6399 *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6400 *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6401 *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6402 *	"radar detected" event.
6403 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6404 *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6405 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6406 *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6407 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6408 *      TXQs.
6409 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6410 *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6411 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6412 *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6413 *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6414 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6415 *	timing measurement responder role.
6416 *
6417 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6418 *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6419 *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6420 *      freeze the connection.
6421 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6422 *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6423 *
6424 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6425 *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6426 *	scheduling.
6427 *
6428 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6429 *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6430 *
6431 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Obsolete
6432 *
6433 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6434 *	to a station.
6435 *
6436 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6437 *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6438 *
6439 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6440 *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6441 *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6442 *
6443 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6444 *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6445 *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6446 *
6447 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6448 *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6449 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6450 *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6451 *
6452 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6453 *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6454 *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6455 *
6456 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6457 *
6458 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6459 *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6460 *
6461 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6462 *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6463 *
6464 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6465 *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6466 *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6467 *	included in the scan request.
6468 *
6469 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6470 *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6471 *
6472 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6473 *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6474 *
6475 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6476 *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6477 *	command).
6478 *
6479 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6480 *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6481 *
6482 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6483 *	frames transmission
6484 *
6485 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6486 *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6487 *
6488 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6489 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6490 *
6491 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6492 *      exchange protocol.
6493 *
6494 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6495 *      exchange protocol.
6496 *
6497 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6498 *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6499 *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6500 *
6501 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6502 *	detection and change announcemnts.
6503 *
6504 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6505 *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6506 *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6507 *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6508 *
6509 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6510 *	detection.
6511 *
6512 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6513 *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6514 *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6515 *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6516 *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6517 *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6518 *	in progress, and no active connections.
6519 *
6520 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6521 *
6522 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6523 *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6524 *
6525 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6526 *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6527 *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6528 *
6529 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6530 *	handling in station mode.
6531 *
6532 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP: Driver/Device wants to do OWE DH IE
6533 *	handling in AP mode.
6534 *
6535 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT: The device supports peer-to-peer or
6536 *	ad hoc operation on DFS channels under the control of a concurrent
6537 *	DFS master on the same channel as described in FCC-594280 D01
6538 *	(Section B.3). This, for example, allows P2P GO and P2P clients to
6539 *	operate on DFS channels as long as there's a concurrent BSS connection.
6540 *
6541 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT: The driver has support for SPP
6542 *	(signaling and payload protected) A-MSDUs and this shall be advertised
6543 *	in the RSNXE.
6544 *
6545 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6546 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6547 */
6548enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6549	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6550	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6551	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6552	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6553	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6554	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6555	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6556	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6557	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6558	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6559	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6560	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6561	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6562	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6563	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6564	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6565	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6566	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6567	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6568	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6569	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6570	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6571	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6572	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6573	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6574	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6575	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6576	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6577	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6578	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6579	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6580	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6581	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6582	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6583	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6584	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6585	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6586	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD, /* obsolete */
6587	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6588	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6589	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6590	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6591	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6592	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6593	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6594	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6595	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6596	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6597	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6598	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6599	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6600	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6601	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6602	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6603	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6604	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6605	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6606	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6607	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6608	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6609	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6610	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6611	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6612	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6613	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6614	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6615	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6616	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD,
6617	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OWE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6618	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_CONCURRENT,
6619	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SPP_AMSDU_SUPPORT,
6620
6621	/* add new features before the definition below */
6622	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6623	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6624};
6625
6626/**
6627 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6628 *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6629 *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6630 *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6631 *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6632 *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6633 *	to the host.
6634 *
6635 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6636 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6637 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6638 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6639 */
6640enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6641	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6642	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6643	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6644	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6645};
6646
6647/**
6648 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6649 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6650 *	handled by the AP is reached.
6651 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6652 */
6653enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6654	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6655	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6656};
6657
6658/**
6659 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6660 *
6661 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6662 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6663 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6664 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6665 */
6666enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6667	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6668	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6669	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6670	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6671};
6672
6673/**
6674 * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6675 *
6676 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6677 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6678 * requests.
6679 *
6680 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6681 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6682 * one of them can be used in the request.
6683 *
6684 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6685 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6686 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6687 *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6688 *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6689 *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6690 *	when really needed
6691 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6692 *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6693 *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6694 *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6695 *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6696 *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6697 *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6698 *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6699 *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6700 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6701 *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6702 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6703 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6704 *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non-OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6705 *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6706 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6707 *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6708 *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6709 *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6710 *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6711 *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6712 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6713 *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6714 *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6715 *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6716 *	impacted with this flag.
6717 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6718 *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6719 *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6720 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6721 *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6722 *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6723 *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6724 *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6725 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6726 *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6727 *	possible.
6728 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6729 *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6730 *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6731 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6732 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6733 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6734 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6735 *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6736 *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6737 *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6738 *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6739 *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6740 *	probe requests on non-PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6741 *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6742 *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6743 *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6744 */
6745enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6746	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6747	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6748	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6749	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6750	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6751	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6752	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6753	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6754	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6755	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6756	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6757	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6758	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6759	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6760	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6761};
6762
6763/**
6764 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6765 *
6766 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6767 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6768 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6769 *
6770 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6771 *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6772 *	in ACL to authenticate.
6773 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6774 *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6775 */
6776enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6777	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6778	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6779};
6780
6781/**
6782 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6783 *
6784 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6785 *
6786 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6787 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6788 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6789 *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6790 */
6791enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6792	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6793	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6794	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6795
6796	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6797	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6798};
6799
6800/**
6801 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6802 *
6803 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6804 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6805 *
6806 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6807 *	now unusable.
6808 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6809 *	the channel is now available.
6810 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6811 *	change to the channel status.
6812 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6813 *	over, channel becomes usable.
6814 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6815 *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6816 *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6817 *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6818 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6819 *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6820 */
6821enum nl80211_radar_event {
6822	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6823	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6824	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6825	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6826	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6827	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6828};
6829
6830/**
6831 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6832 *
6833 * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6834 *
6835 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6836 *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6837 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6838 *	is therefore marked as not available.
6839 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6840 */
6841enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6842	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6843	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6844	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6845};
6846
6847/**
6848 * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6849 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6850 *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6851 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6852 *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6853 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6854 */
6855enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6856	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6857};
6858
6859/**
6860 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6861 *
6862 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6863 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6864 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6865 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6866 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6867 */
6868enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6869	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6870	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6871	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6872	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6873	/* add other protocols before this one */
6874	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6875};
6876
6877/* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6878#define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6879
6880/**
6881 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6882 *
6883 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6884 *
6885 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6886 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6887 *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6888 *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6889 *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6890 */
6891enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6892	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6893	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6894};
6895
6896/*
6897 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6898 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6899 * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6900 */
6901#define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6902
6903/**
6904 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6905 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6906 *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6907 *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6908 *	added to this file when needed.
6909 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6910 */
6911struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6912	__u32 vendor_id;
6913	__u32 subcmd;
6914};
6915
6916/**
6917 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6918 *
6919 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6920 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6921 *
6922 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6923 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6924 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6925 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6926 */
6927enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6928	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6929	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6930	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6931	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6932};
6933
6934/**
6935 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6936 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6937 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6938 *	seconds (u32).
6939 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6940 *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6941 *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6942 *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6943 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6944 *	currently defined
6945 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6946 */
6947enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6948	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6949	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6950	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6951
6952	/* keep last */
6953	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6954	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6955		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6956};
6957
6958/**
6959 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6960 *
6961 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6962 *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6963 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6964 */
6965struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6966	__u8 band;
6967	__s8 delta;
6968} __attribute__((packed));
6969
6970/**
6971 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6972 *
6973 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6974 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6975 *	is requested.
6976 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6977 *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6978 *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6979 *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6980 *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6981 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6982 *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6983 *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6984 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6985 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6986 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6987 *
6988 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6989 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6990 * which the driver shall use.
6991 */
6992enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6993	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6994	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6995	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6996	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6997
6998	/* keep last */
6999	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
7000	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
7001};
7002
7003/**
7004 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
7005 *
7006 * Defines the function type of a NAN function
7007 *
7008 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
7009 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
7010 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
7011 */
7012enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
7013	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
7014	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
7015	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
7016
7017	/* keep last */
7018	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
7019	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
7020};
7021
7022/**
7023 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
7024 *
7025 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
7026 *
7027 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
7028 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
7029 */
7030enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
7031	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
7032	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
7033};
7034
7035/**
7036 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
7037 *
7038 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
7039 *
7040 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
7041 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
7042 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
7043 */
7044enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
7045	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
7046	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
7047	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
7048};
7049
7050#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
7051#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
7052#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
7053
7054/**
7055 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
7056 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
7057 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
7058 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
7059 *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
7060 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
7061 *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
7062 *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
7063 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
7064 *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
7065 *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
7066 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
7067 *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
7068 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
7069 *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
7070 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
7071 *	is follow up. This is a u8.
7072 *	The requester instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
7073 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
7074 *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
7075 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
7076 *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
7077 *	This is a flag.
7078 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
7079 *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
7080 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
7081 *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
7082 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
7083 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
7084 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
7085 *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7086 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
7087 *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
7088 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
7089 *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
7090 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
7091 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
7092 *
7093 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
7094 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
7095 */
7096enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
7097	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
7098	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
7099	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
7100	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
7101	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
7102	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
7103	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
7104	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
7105	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
7106	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
7107	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
7108	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
7109	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
7110	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
7111	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
7112	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
7113	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
7114
7115	/* keep last */
7116	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
7117	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
7118};
7119
7120/**
7121 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
7122 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
7123 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
7124 *	This is a flag.
7125 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
7126 *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
7127 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
7128 *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
7129 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
7130 *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
7131 *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
7132 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
7133 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
7134 */
7135enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
7136	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
7137	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
7138	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
7139	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
7140	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
7141
7142	/* keep last */
7143	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
7144	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
7145};
7146
7147/**
7148 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
7149 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
7150 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
7151 *	match. This is a nested attribute.
7152 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7153 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
7154 *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
7155 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
7156 *
7157 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
7158 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
7159 */
7160enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
7161	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
7162	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
7163	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
7164
7165	/* keep last */
7166	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
7167	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
7168};
7169
7170/**
7171 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
7172 *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
7173 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7174 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7175 */
7176enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7177	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7178	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7179};
7180
7181/**
7182 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7183 *	responder attributes
7184 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7185 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7186 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7187 *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7188 *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7189 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7190 *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7191 *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7192 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7193 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7194 */
7195enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7196	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7197
7198	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7199	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7200	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7201
7202	/* keep last */
7203	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7204	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7205};
7206
7207/*
7208 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7209 *
7210 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7211 * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7212 *
7213 * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7214 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7215 *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7216 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7217 *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7218 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7219 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7220 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7221 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7222 *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7223 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7224 *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7225 *	phase with the responder (u32)
7226 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7227 *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7228 *	FTM slot (u32)
7229 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7230 *	scheduled window (u32)
7231 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7232 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7233 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7234 */
7235enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7236	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7237	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7238	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7239	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7240	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7241	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7242	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7243	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7244	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7245	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7246	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7247
7248	/* keep last */
7249	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7250	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7251};
7252
7253/**
7254 * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7255 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7256 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7257 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7258 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7259 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7260 */
7261enum nl80211_preamble {
7262	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7263	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7264	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7265	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7266	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7267};
7268
7269/**
7270 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7271 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7272 *	these numbers also for attributes
7273 *
7274 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7275 *
7276 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7277 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7278 */
7279enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7280	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7281
7282	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7283
7284	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7285	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7286};
7287
7288/**
7289 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7290 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7291 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7292 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7293 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7294 *	reason may be available in the response data
7295 */
7296enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7297	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7298	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7299	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7300	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7301};
7302
7303/**
7304 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7305 * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7306 *
7307 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7308 *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7309 *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7310 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7311 *	(flag attribute)
7312 *
7313 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7314 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7315 */
7316enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7317	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7318
7319	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7320	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7321
7322	/* keep last */
7323	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7324	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7325};
7326
7327/**
7328 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7329 * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7330 *
7331 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7332 *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7333 *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7334 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7335 *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7336 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7337 *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7338 *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7339 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7340 *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7341 *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7342 *	(u64, usec)
7343 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7344 *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7345 *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7346 *	result.
7347 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7348 *
7349 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7350 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7351 */
7352enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7353	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7354
7355	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7356	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7357	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7358	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7359	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7360	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7361
7362	/* keep last */
7363	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7364	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7365};
7366
7367/**
7368 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7369 * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7370 *
7371 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7372 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7373 *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7374 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7375 *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7376 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7377 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7378 *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7379 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7380 *
7381 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7382 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7383 */
7384enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7385	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7386
7387	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7388	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7389	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7390	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7391
7392	/* keep last */
7393	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7394	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7395};
7396
7397/**
7398 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7399 * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7400 *
7401 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7402 *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7403 *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7404 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7405 *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7406 *	measurement results
7407 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7408 *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7409 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7410 *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7411 *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7412 *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7413 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7414 *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7415 *	sub-attributes taken from
7416 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7417 *
7418 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7419 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7420 */
7421enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7422	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7423
7424	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7425	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7426	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7427	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7428	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7429
7430	/* keep last */
7431	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7432	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7433};
7434
7435/**
7436 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7437 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7438 *
7439 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7440 *	is supported
7441 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7442 *	mode is supported
7443 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7444 *	data can be requested during the measurement
7445 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7446 *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7447 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7448 *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7449 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7450 *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7451 *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7452 *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7453 *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7454 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7455 *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7456 *	is valid)
7457 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7458 *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7459 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7460 *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7461 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7462 *	if non-trigger-based ranging measurement is supported
7463 *
7464 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7465 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7466 */
7467enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7468	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7469
7470	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7471	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7472	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7473	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7474	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7475	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7476	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7477	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7478	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7479	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7480
7481	/* keep last */
7482	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7483	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7484};
7485
7486/**
7487 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7488 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7489 *
7490 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7491 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7492 *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7493 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7494 *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7495 *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7496 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7497 *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7498 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7499 *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7500 *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7501 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7502 *	requested per burst
7503 *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7504 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7505 *	(u8, default 3)
7506 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7507 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7508 *	(flag)
7509 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7510 *	measurement (flag).
7511 *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7512 *	mutually exclusive.
7513 *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7514 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7515 *	ranging will be used.
7516 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non-trigger-based
7517 *	ranging measurement (flag)
7518 *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7519 *	mutually exclusive.
7520 *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7521 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7522 *	ranging will be used.
7523 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7524 *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7525 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7526 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7527 *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7528 *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7529 *
7530 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7531 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7532 */
7533enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7534	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7535
7536	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7537	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7538	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7539	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7540	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7541	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7542	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7543	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7544	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7545	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7546	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7547	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7548	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7549
7550	/* keep last */
7551	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7552	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7553};
7554
7555/**
7556 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7557 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7558 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7559 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7560 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7561 *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7562 *	try and get no response)
7563 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7564 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7565 *	received
7566 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7567 *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7568 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7569 *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7570 */
7571enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7572	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7573	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7574	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7575	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7576	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7577	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7578	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7579	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7580};
7581
7582/**
7583 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7584 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7585 *
7586 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7587 *	(u32, optional)
7588 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7589 *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7590 *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7591 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7592 *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7593 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7594 *	that were acknowledged (u32, optional)
7595 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7596 *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7597 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7598 *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7599 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7600 *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7601 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7602 *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7603 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7604 *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7605 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7606 *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7607 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7608 *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7609 *	attributes)
7610 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7611 *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7612 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7613 *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7614 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7615 *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7616 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7617 *	optional)
7618 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7619 *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7620 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7621 *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7622 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7623 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7624 *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7625 *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7626 *	Type 8.
7627 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7628 *	(binary, optional);
7629 *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7630 *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7631 *	Type 11.
7632 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7633 *
7634 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7635 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7636 */
7637enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7638	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7639
7640	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7641	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7642	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7643	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7644	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7645	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7646	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7647	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7648	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7649	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7650	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7651	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7652	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7653	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7654	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7655	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7656	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7657	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7658	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7659	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7660	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7661
7662	/* keep last */
7663	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7664	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7665};
7666
7667/**
7668 * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7669 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7670 *
7671 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7672 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7673 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7674 *	tx power offset.
7675 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7676 *	values used by members of the SRG.
7677 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7678 *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7679 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7680 *
7681 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7682 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7683 */
7684enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7685	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7686
7687	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7688	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7689	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7690	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7691	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7692	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7693
7694	/* keep last */
7695	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7696	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7697};
7698
7699/**
7700 * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7701 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7702 *
7703 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7704 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7705 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7706 *
7707 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7708 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7709 */
7710enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7711	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7712
7713	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7714	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7715	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7716
7717	/* keep last */
7718	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7719	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7720};
7721
7722/**
7723 * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7724 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7725 *
7726 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7727 *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7728 *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7729 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7730 *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7731 *
7732 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7733 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7734 */
7735enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7736	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7737
7738	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7739	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7740
7741	/* keep last */
7742	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7743	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7744};
7745
7746/**
7747 * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7748 * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7749 *
7750 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7751 *
7752 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7753 *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7754 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7755 *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit). If set to 0, the feature is disabled.
7756 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7757 *	frame including the headers.
7758 *
7759 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7760 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7761 */
7762enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7763	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7764
7765	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7766	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7767	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7768
7769	/* keep last */
7770	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7771	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7772};
7773
7774/*
7775 * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7776 * mandatory fields.
7777 */
7778#define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7779
7780/**
7781 * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7782 *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7783 *
7784 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7785 *
7786 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7787 *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7788 *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning). If set to 0, the feature is
7789 *	disabled.
7790 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7791 *	frame template (binary).
7792 *
7793 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7794 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7795 */
7796enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7797	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7798
7799	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7800	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7801
7802	/* keep last */
7803	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7804	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7805		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7806};
7807
7808/**
7809 * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7810 *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7811 *	used.
7812 *
7813 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7814 *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7815 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7816 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7817 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7818 *	can be used.
7819 */
7820enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7821	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7822	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7823	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7824	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7825};
7826
7827/**
7828 * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7829 *
7830 * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7831 *
7832 */
7833enum nl80211_sar_type {
7834	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7835
7836	/* add new type here */
7837
7838	/* Keep last */
7839	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7840};
7841
7842/**
7843 * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7844 *
7845 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7846 *
7847 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7848 *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7849 *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7850 *
7851 *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7852 *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7853 *
7854 *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7855 *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7856 *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7857 *
7858 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7859 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7860 *
7861 * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7862 */
7863enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7864	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7865
7866	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7867	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7868
7869	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7870	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7871};
7872
7873/**
7874 * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7875 *
7876 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7877 *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7878 *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7879 *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7880 *
7881 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7882 *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7883 *	is applied to this range.
7884 *
7885 *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7886 *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7887 *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7888 *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7889 *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7890 *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7891 *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7892 *
7893 *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7894 *
7895 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7896 *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7897 *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7898 *
7899 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7900 *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7901 *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7902 *
7903 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7904 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7905 */
7906enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7907	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7908
7909	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7910	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7911	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7912	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7913
7914	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7915	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7916};
7917
7918/**
7919 * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
7920 * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
7921 * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
7922 * MBSSID and EMA.
7923 * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
7924 * features.
7925 *
7926 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7927 *
7928 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
7929 *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
7930 *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
7931 *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
7932 *
7933 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
7934 *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
7935 *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
7936 *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
7937 *	a non-zero value.
7938 *
7939 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
7940 *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
7941 *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
7942 *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
7943 *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
7944 *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
7945 *
7946 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
7947 *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
7948 *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
7949 *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
7950 *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
7951 *	the interface index of the same.
7952 *
7953 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
7954 *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
7955 *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
7956 *
7957 * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7958 * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7959 */
7960enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
7961	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
7962
7963	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
7964	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
7965	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
7966	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
7967	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
7968
7969	/* keep last */
7970	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
7971	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7972};
7973
7974/**
7975 * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
7976 *
7977 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
7978 *	authentication.
7979 * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
7980 *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
7981 *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
7982 *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
7983 *	userspace.
7984 */
7985enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
7986	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
7987	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
7988};
7989
7990#endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
7991